1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed. 345 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: TID to link mapping was changed 346 */ 347 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 348 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 350 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 351 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 352 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 356 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 357 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 358 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 359 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 360 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 361 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 362 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 363 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 364 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 365 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 366 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 367 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 368 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 369 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 370 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 372 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 373 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 374 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 375 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 376 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 377 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 378 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 379 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 380 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 381 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33), 382 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34), 383 384 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 385 }; 386 387 /* 388 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 389 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 390 * filtering will be disabled. 391 */ 392 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 393 394 /** 395 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 396 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 397 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 398 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 399 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 400 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 401 * once each time the timeout triggers. 402 */ 403 enum ieee80211_event_type { 404 RSSI_EVENT, 405 MLME_EVENT, 406 BAR_RX_EVENT, 407 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 408 }; 409 410 /** 411 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 412 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 413 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 414 */ 415 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 416 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 417 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 418 }; 419 420 /** 421 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 422 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 423 */ 424 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 425 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 426 }; 427 428 /** 429 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 430 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 431 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 432 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 433 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 434 */ 435 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 436 AUTH_EVENT, 437 ASSOC_EVENT, 438 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 439 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 440 }; 441 442 /** 443 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 444 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 445 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 446 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 447 */ 448 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 449 MLME_SUCCESS, 450 MLME_DENIED, 451 MLME_TIMEOUT, 452 }; 453 454 /** 455 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 456 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 457 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 458 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 459 */ 460 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 461 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 462 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 463 u16 reason; 464 }; 465 466 /** 467 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 468 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 469 * @tid: the tid 470 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 471 */ 472 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 473 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 474 u16 tid; 475 u16 ssn; 476 }; 477 478 /** 479 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 480 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 481 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 482 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 483 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 484 * @u:union holding the fields above 485 */ 486 struct ieee80211_event { 487 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 488 union { 489 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 490 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 491 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 492 } u; 493 }; 494 495 /** 496 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 497 * 498 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 499 * 500 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 501 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 502 */ 503 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 504 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 505 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 506 }; 507 508 /** 509 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 510 * 511 * @lci: LCI subelement content 512 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 513 * @lci_len: LCI data length 514 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 515 */ 516 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 517 const u8 *lci; 518 const u8 *civicloc; 519 size_t lci_len; 520 size_t civicloc_len; 521 }; 522 523 /** 524 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 525 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 526 * 527 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 528 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 529 */ 530 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 531 u32 min_interval; 532 u32 max_interval; 533 }; 534 535 /** 536 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 537 * 538 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 539 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 540 * 541 * @vif: reference to owning VIF 542 * @addr: (link) address used locally 543 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 544 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 545 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 546 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 547 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 548 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 549 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 551 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 552 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 553 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 554 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 555 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 556 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 557 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 558 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 559 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 560 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 561 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 562 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 563 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 564 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 565 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 566 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 567 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 568 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 569 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 570 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 571 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 572 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 573 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 574 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 575 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 576 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 577 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 578 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 579 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 580 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 581 * the current band. 582 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 583 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 584 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 585 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 586 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 587 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 588 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 589 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 590 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 591 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 592 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 593 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 594 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 595 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 596 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 597 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 598 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 599 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 600 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 601 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 602 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 603 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 604 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 605 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 606 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 607 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 609 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 610 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 611 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 612 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 613 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 614 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 615 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 616 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 617 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 618 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 619 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 620 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 621 * station. 622 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 623 * responder functionality. 624 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 625 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 626 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 627 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 628 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 629 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 630 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 631 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 632 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 633 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 634 * connected to (STA) 635 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 636 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 637 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 638 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 639 * interval. 640 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 641 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 642 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 643 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 644 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 645 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 646 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 647 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 648 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. 649 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 650 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 651 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 652 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 653 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 654 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 655 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 656 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. 657 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 658 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability. 659 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability. 660 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability. 661 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 662 * beamformer 663 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 664 * beamformee 665 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 666 * beamformer 667 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 668 * beamformee 669 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 670 * beamformer 671 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 672 * beamformee 673 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 674 * beamformer 675 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 676 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 677 * bandwidth 678 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 679 * beamformer 680 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 681 * beamformee 682 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU 683 * beamformer 684 */ 685 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 686 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 687 688 const u8 *bssid; 689 unsigned int link_id; 690 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 691 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 692 bool uora_exists; 693 u8 uora_ocw_range; 694 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 695 bool he_support; 696 bool twt_requester; 697 bool twt_responder; 698 bool twt_protected; 699 bool twt_broadcast; 700 /* erp related data */ 701 bool use_cts_prot; 702 bool use_short_preamble; 703 bool use_short_slot; 704 bool enable_beacon; 705 u8 dtim_period; 706 u16 beacon_int; 707 u16 assoc_capability; 708 u64 sync_tsf; 709 u32 sync_device_ts; 710 u8 sync_dtim_count; 711 u32 basic_rates; 712 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 713 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 714 u16 ht_operation_mode; 715 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 716 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 717 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 718 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 719 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 720 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 721 bool qos; 722 bool hidden_ssid; 723 int txpower; 724 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 725 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 726 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 727 u16 max_idle_period; 728 bool protected_keep_alive; 729 bool ftm_responder; 730 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 731 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 732 bool nontransmitted; 733 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 734 u8 bssid_index; 735 u8 bssid_indicator; 736 bool ema_ap; 737 u8 profile_periodicity; 738 struct { 739 u32 params; 740 u16 nss_set; 741 } he_oper; 742 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 743 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 744 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 745 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 746 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 747 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 748 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 749 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 750 u8 pwr_reduction; 751 bool eht_support; 752 u16 eht_puncturing; 753 754 bool csa_active; 755 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 756 757 bool mu_mimo_owner; 758 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 759 760 bool color_change_active; 761 u8 color_change_color; 762 763 bool ht_ldpc; 764 bool vht_ldpc; 765 bool he_ldpc; 766 bool vht_su_beamformer; 767 bool vht_su_beamformee; 768 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 769 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 770 bool he_su_beamformer; 771 bool he_su_beamformee; 772 bool he_mu_beamformer; 773 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 774 bool eht_su_beamformer; 775 bool eht_su_beamformee; 776 bool eht_mu_beamformer; 777 }; 778 779 /** 780 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 781 * 782 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 783 * 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 785 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 786 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 787 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 788 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 789 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 790 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 791 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 792 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 793 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 794 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 795 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 796 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 798 * station 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 800 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 802 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 803 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 804 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 805 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 806 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 807 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 808 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 809 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 810 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 811 * hardware queue. 812 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 813 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 814 * is for the whole aggregation. 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 816 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 817 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 818 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 819 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 820 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 821 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 822 * off-channel operation. 823 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 824 * (header conversion) 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 826 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 828 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 829 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 830 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 831 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 832 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 833 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 834 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 835 * queue gets full. 836 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 837 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 838 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 839 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 840 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 841 * should kick the MLME state machine. 842 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 843 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 844 * status to user space) 845 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 846 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 847 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 849 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 850 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 851 * handled properly by the device. 852 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 853 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 854 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 855 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 856 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 857 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 858 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 859 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 860 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 861 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 862 * PS-Poll responses. 863 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 864 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 865 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 866 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 867 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 868 * monitor injection). 869 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 870 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 871 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 872 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 873 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 874 * 875 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 876 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 877 */ 878 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 879 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 880 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 887 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 888 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 889 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 890 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 891 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 892 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 893 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 894 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 895 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 896 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 897 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 898 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 899 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 900 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 901 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 902 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 904 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 906 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 907 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 908 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 909 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 910 }; 911 912 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 913 914 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 915 916 /** 917 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 918 * 919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 920 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 922 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 924 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 927 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 928 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 929 * it can be sent out. 930 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 931 * has already been assigned to this frame. 932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 933 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 934 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 935 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 936 * for sequence number assignment 937 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 938 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 939 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 940 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 941 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 942 * it's intended for an MLD. 943 * 944 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 945 */ 946 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 947 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 948 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 949 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 950 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 951 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 953 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 955 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 956 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 957 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 958 }; 959 960 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 961 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 962 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 963 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 964 965 /** 966 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 967 * 968 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 969 * 970 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 971 */ 972 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 973 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 974 }; 975 976 /* 977 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 978 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 979 */ 980 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 981 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 982 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 983 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 984 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 985 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 986 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 988 989 /** 990 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 991 * Rate Control algorithm. 992 * 993 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 994 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 995 * 996 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 997 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 998 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 999 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 1002 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 1004 * Greenfield mode. 1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 1008 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 1009 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 1010 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 1011 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 1013 */ 1014 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 1015 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1016 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1017 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1018 1019 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1020 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1021 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1023 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1024 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1025 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1026 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1027 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1028 }; 1029 1030 1031 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1032 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1033 1034 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1035 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1036 1037 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1038 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1039 1040 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1041 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1042 1043 /** 1044 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1045 * 1046 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1047 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1048 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1049 * 1050 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1051 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1052 * 1053 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1054 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1055 * 1056 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1057 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1058 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1059 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1060 * information:: 1061 * 1062 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1063 * 1064 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1065 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1066 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1067 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1068 * information should then contain:: 1069 * 1070 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1071 * 1072 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1073 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1074 */ 1075 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1076 s8 idx; 1077 u16 count:5, 1078 flags:11; 1079 } __packed; 1080 1081 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1082 1083 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1084 { 1085 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0; 1086 } 1087 1088 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1089 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1090 { 1091 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1092 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1093 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1094 } 1095 1096 static inline u8 1097 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1098 { 1099 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1100 } 1101 1102 static inline u8 1103 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1104 { 1105 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1106 } 1107 1108 /** 1109 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1110 * 1111 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1112 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1113 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1114 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1115 * 1116 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1117 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1118 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1119 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1120 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1121 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately, 1122 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation 1123 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame 1124 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1125 * @control: union part for control data 1126 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1127 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1128 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1129 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1130 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1131 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1132 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1133 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1134 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1135 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1136 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1137 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1138 * @pad: padding 1139 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1140 * @status: union part for status data 1141 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1142 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1143 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1144 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1145 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1146 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1147 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1148 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1149 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1150 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1151 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1152 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1153 */ 1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1155 /* common information */ 1156 u32 flags; 1157 u32 band:3, 1158 status_data_idr:1, 1159 status_data:13, 1160 hw_queue:4, 1161 tx_time_est:10; 1162 /* 1 free bit */ 1163 1164 union { 1165 struct { 1166 union { 1167 /* rate control */ 1168 struct { 1169 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1170 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1171 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1172 u8 use_rts:1; 1173 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1174 u8 short_preamble:1; 1175 u8 skip_table:1; 1176 1177 /* for injection only (bitmap) */ 1178 u8 antennas:2; 1179 1180 /* 14 bits free */ 1181 }; 1182 /* only needed before rate control */ 1183 unsigned long jiffies; 1184 }; 1185 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1186 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1187 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1188 u32 flags; 1189 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1190 } control; 1191 struct { 1192 u64 cookie; 1193 } ack; 1194 struct { 1195 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1196 s32 ack_signal; 1197 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1198 u8 ampdu_len; 1199 u8 antenna; 1200 u8 pad; 1201 u16 tx_time; 1202 u8 flags; 1203 u8 pad2; 1204 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)]; 1205 } status; 1206 struct { 1207 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1208 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1209 u8 pad[4]; 1210 1211 void *rate_driver_data[ 1212 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1213 }; 1214 void *driver_data[ 1215 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1216 }; 1217 }; 1218 1219 static inline u16 1220 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1221 { 1222 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1223 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1224 */ 1225 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1226 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1227 } 1228 1229 static inline u16 1230 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1231 { 1232 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1233 } 1234 1235 /*** 1236 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1237 * 1238 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1239 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1240 * 1241 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1242 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1243 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1244 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1245 * that was used when sending the packet. 1246 */ 1247 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1248 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1249 u8 try_count; 1250 u8 tx_power_idx; 1251 }; 1252 1253 /** 1254 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1255 * 1256 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1257 * @info: Basic tx status information 1258 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1259 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1260 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1261 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1262 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1263 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1264 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1265 */ 1266 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1267 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1268 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1269 struct sk_buff *skb; 1270 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1271 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1272 u8 n_rates; 1273 1274 struct list_head *free_list; 1275 }; 1276 1277 /** 1278 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1279 * 1280 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1281 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1282 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1283 * 1284 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1285 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1286 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1287 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1288 */ 1289 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1290 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1291 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1292 const u8 *common_ies; 1293 size_t common_ie_len; 1294 }; 1295 1296 1297 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1298 { 1299 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1300 } 1301 1302 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1303 { 1304 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1305 } 1306 1307 /** 1308 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1309 * 1310 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1311 * 1312 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1313 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1314 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1315 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1316 * 1317 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1318 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1319 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1320 */ 1321 static inline void 1322 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1323 { 1324 int i; 1325 1326 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1327 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1328 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1329 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1330 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1331 /* clear the rate counts */ 1332 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1333 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1334 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1335 } 1336 1337 1338 /** 1339 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1340 * 1341 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1342 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1343 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1344 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1345 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1346 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1347 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1348 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1349 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1350 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1351 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1352 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1353 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1354 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1355 * de-duplication by itself. 1356 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1357 * the frame. 1358 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1359 * the frame. 1360 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1361 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position 1362 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value. 1363 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1364 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1365 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1366 * merging. 1367 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1368 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1369 * (including FCS) was received. 1370 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1371 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1372 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime 1373 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid 1374 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see 1375 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is 1376 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32. 1377 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1378 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1379 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1380 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1381 * each A-MPDU 1382 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1383 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1384 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1385 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1386 * on this subframe 1387 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1388 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1389 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1390 * done by the hardware 1391 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1392 * processing it in any regular way. 1393 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1394 * them for sniffing purposes. 1395 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1396 * monitor interfaces. 1397 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1398 * them for sniffing purposes. 1399 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1400 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1401 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1402 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1403 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1404 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1405 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1406 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1407 * interleaved with other frames. 1408 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the 1409 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header). 1410 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point 1411 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV 1412 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs 1413 * in the skb. 1414 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1415 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1416 * the first subframe. 1417 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1418 * be done in the hardware. 1419 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1420 * frame 1421 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1422 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1423 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1424 * 1425 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1426 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1427 * - DATA3_CODING 1428 * - DATA5_GI 1429 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1430 * - DATA6_NSTS 1431 * - DATA3_STBC 1432 * 1433 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1434 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1435 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1436 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1437 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1438 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1439 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1440 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1441 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1442 * hardware or driver) 1443 */ 1444 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1445 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1446 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1447 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2), 1448 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1449 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1450 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1451 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1452 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7), 1453 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1454 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1455 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1456 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1457 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1458 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1459 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1460 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1461 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17), 1462 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16, 1463 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16, 1464 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16, 1465 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1466 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1467 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20), 1468 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1469 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1470 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1471 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1472 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1473 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1474 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1475 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1476 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1477 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1478 }; 1479 1480 /** 1481 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1482 * 1483 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1484 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1485 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1486 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1487 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1488 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1489 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1490 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1491 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1492 */ 1493 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1494 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1495 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1496 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1497 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1498 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1499 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1500 }; 1501 1502 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1503 1504 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1505 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1506 RX_ENC_HT, 1507 RX_ENC_VHT, 1508 RX_ENC_HE, 1509 RX_ENC_EHT, 1510 }; 1511 1512 /** 1513 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1514 * 1515 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1516 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1517 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1518 * 1519 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1520 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1521 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1522 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1523 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1524 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1525 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1526 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1527 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1528 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1529 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1530 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1531 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1532 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1533 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1534 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1535 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1536 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1537 * values were filled. 1538 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1539 * support dB or unspecified units) 1540 * @antenna: antenna used 1541 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1542 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1543 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1544 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1545 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1546 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1547 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1548 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1549 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1550 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1551 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1552 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1553 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1554 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1555 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1556 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1557 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1558 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1559 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1560 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1561 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1562 * @link_valid. 1563 */ 1564 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1565 u64 mactime; 1566 union { 1567 u64 boottime_ns; 1568 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1569 }; 1570 u32 device_timestamp; 1571 u32 ampdu_reference; 1572 u32 flag; 1573 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1574 u8 enc_flags; 1575 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1576 union { 1577 struct { 1578 u8 he_ru:3; 1579 u8 he_gi:2; 1580 u8 he_dcm:1; 1581 }; 1582 struct { 1583 u8 ru:4; 1584 u8 gi:2; 1585 } eht; 1586 }; 1587 u8 rate_idx; 1588 u8 nss; 1589 u8 rx_flags; 1590 u8 band; 1591 u8 antenna; 1592 s8 signal; 1593 u8 chains; 1594 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1595 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1596 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1597 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1598 }; 1599 1600 static inline u32 1601 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1602 { 1603 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1604 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1605 } 1606 1607 /** 1608 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1609 * 1610 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1611 * 1612 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1613 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1614 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1615 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1616 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1617 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1618 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1619 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1620 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1621 * for more. 1622 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1623 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1624 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1625 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1626 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1627 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1628 * operating channel. 1629 */ 1630 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1631 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1632 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1633 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1634 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1635 }; 1636 1637 1638 /** 1639 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1640 * 1641 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1642 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1643 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1644 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1645 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1646 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1647 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1648 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1649 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1650 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1651 */ 1652 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1653 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1654 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1655 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1656 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1657 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1658 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1659 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1660 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1661 }; 1662 1663 /** 1664 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1665 * 1666 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1667 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1668 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1669 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1670 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1671 */ 1672 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1673 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1674 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1675 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1676 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1677 1678 /* keep last */ 1679 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1680 }; 1681 1682 /** 1683 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1684 * 1685 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1686 * 1687 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1688 * 1689 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1690 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1691 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1692 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1693 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1694 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1695 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1696 * 1697 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1698 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1699 * 1700 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1701 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1702 * 1703 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1704 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1705 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1706 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1707 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1708 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1709 * 1710 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1711 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1712 * configured for an HT channel. 1713 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1714 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1715 */ 1716 struct ieee80211_conf { 1717 u32 flags; 1718 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1719 1720 u16 listen_interval; 1721 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1722 1723 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1724 1725 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1726 bool radar_enabled; 1727 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1728 }; 1729 1730 /** 1731 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1732 * 1733 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1734 * operation. 1735 * 1736 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1737 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1738 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1739 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1740 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1741 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1742 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1743 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1744 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1745 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1746 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1747 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1748 * channel, expressed in TU. 1749 */ 1750 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1751 u64 timestamp; 1752 u32 device_timestamp; 1753 bool block_tx; 1754 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1755 u8 count; 1756 u32 delay; 1757 }; 1758 1759 /** 1760 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1761 * 1762 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1763 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1764 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1765 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1766 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1767 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1768 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1769 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1770 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1771 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1772 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1773 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1774 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1775 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is 1776 * enabled for the interface. 1777 */ 1778 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1779 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1780 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1781 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1782 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1783 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4), 1784 }; 1785 1786 1787 /** 1788 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1789 * 1790 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1791 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1792 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1793 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1794 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1795 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1796 * mac80211. 1797 */ 1798 1799 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1800 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1801 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1802 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1803 }; 1804 1805 /** 1806 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1807 * @assoc: association status 1808 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1809 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1810 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1811 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1812 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1813 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j. 1814 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in 1815 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i. 1816 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1 1817 * Figure 9-1001k 1818 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1819 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1820 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1821 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1822 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1823 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1824 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1825 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1826 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1827 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1828 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1829 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1830 * your driver/device needs to do. 1831 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1832 * (station mode only) 1833 */ 1834 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1835 /* association related data */ 1836 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1837 bool ibss_creator; 1838 bool ps; 1839 u16 aid; 1840 u16 eml_cap; 1841 u16 eml_med_sync_delay; 1842 u16 mld_capa_op; 1843 1844 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1845 int arp_addr_cnt; 1846 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1847 size_t ssid_len; 1848 bool s1g; 1849 bool idle; 1850 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1851 }; 1852 1853 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8 1854 1855 /** 1856 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info 1857 * 1858 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for 1859 * this TID is not included. 1860 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this 1861 * TID is not included. 1862 * @valid: info is valid or not. 1863 */ 1864 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm { 1865 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS]; 1866 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS]; 1867 bool valid; 1868 }; 1869 1870 /** 1871 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling 1872 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request 1873 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request 1874 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping 1875 */ 1876 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res { 1877 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT, 1878 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT, 1879 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED 1880 }; 1881 1882 /** 1883 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1884 * 1885 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1886 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1887 * 1888 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1889 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1890 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1891 * or the BSS we're associated to 1892 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1893 * indexed by link ID 1894 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1895 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1896 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1897 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1898 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1899 * Must be a subset of valid_links. 1900 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are 1901 * suspended. 1902 * 0 for non-MLO. 1903 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info. 1904 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm. 1905 * @addr: address of this interface 1906 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1907 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1908 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1909 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1910 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1911 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1912 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1913 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1914 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1915 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1916 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1917 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1918 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1919 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1920 * restrictions. 1921 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1922 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1923 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1924 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1925 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1926 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1927 * interface. 1928 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1929 * for this interface. 1930 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1931 * sizeof(void \*). 1932 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1933 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1934 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1935 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1936 */ 1937 struct ieee80211_vif { 1938 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1939 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1940 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1941 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1942 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links; 1943 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm; 1944 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1945 bool p2p; 1946 1947 u8 cab_queue; 1948 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1949 1950 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1951 1952 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1953 u32 driver_flags; 1954 u32 offload_flags; 1955 1956 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1957 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1958 #endif 1959 1960 bool probe_req_reg; 1961 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1962 1963 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1964 1965 /* must be last */ 1966 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1967 }; 1968 1969 /** 1970 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif 1971 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested 1972 * Return: the usable link bitmap 1973 */ 1974 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1975 { 1976 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links; 1977 } 1978 1979 /** 1980 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one 1981 * @vif: the vif 1982 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise. 1983 */ 1984 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1985 { 1986 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */ 1987 return vif->valid_links != 0; 1988 } 1989 1990 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1991 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1992 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1993 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1994 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id))) 1995 1996 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1997 { 1998 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1999 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 2000 #endif 2001 return false; 2002 } 2003 2004 /** 2005 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 2006 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 2007 * 2008 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 2009 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 2010 * 2011 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 2012 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 2013 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 2014 */ 2015 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 2016 2017 /** 2018 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 2019 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 2020 * 2021 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 2022 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 2023 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 2024 */ 2025 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 2026 2027 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 2028 { 2029 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx); 2030 } 2031 2032 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 2033 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 2034 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif)) 2035 2036 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 2037 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 2038 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif)) 2039 2040 /** 2041 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 2042 * 2043 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 2044 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 2045 * 2046 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 2047 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 2048 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 2049 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 2050 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 2051 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 2052 * generation in software. 2053 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 2054 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 2055 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 2056 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 2057 * (MFP) to be done in software. 2058 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 2059 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 2060 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 2061 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 2062 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 2063 * MIC. 2064 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 2065 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 2066 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 2067 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 2068 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 2069 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2070 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2071 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2072 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2073 * only for management frames (MFP). 2074 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2075 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2076 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2077 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2078 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2079 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2080 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2081 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2082 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2083 * generation only 2084 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key 2085 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag) 2086 */ 2087 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2088 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2089 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2090 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2091 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2092 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2093 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2094 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2095 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2096 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2097 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2098 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2099 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11), 2100 }; 2101 2102 /** 2103 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2104 * 2105 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2106 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2107 * 2108 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2109 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2110 * encrypted in hardware. 2111 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2112 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2113 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2114 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2115 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2116 * @keylen: key material length 2117 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2118 * data block: 2119 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2120 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2121 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2122 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2123 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2124 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2125 */ 2126 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2127 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2128 u32 cipher; 2129 u8 icv_len; 2130 u8 iv_len; 2131 u8 hw_key_idx; 2132 s8 keyidx; 2133 u16 flags; 2134 s8 link_id; 2135 u8 keylen; 2136 u8 key[]; 2137 }; 2138 2139 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2140 2141 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2142 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2143 2144 /** 2145 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2146 * 2147 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2148 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2149 * reverse order than in packet) 2150 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2151 * reverse order than in packet) 2152 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2153 * reverse order than in packet) 2154 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2155 * reverse order than in packet) 2156 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2157 */ 2158 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2159 union { 2160 struct { 2161 u32 iv32; 2162 u16 iv16; 2163 } tkip; 2164 struct { 2165 u8 pn[6]; 2166 } ccmp; 2167 struct { 2168 u8 pn[6]; 2169 } aes_cmac; 2170 struct { 2171 u8 pn[6]; 2172 } aes_gmac; 2173 struct { 2174 u8 pn[6]; 2175 } gcmp; 2176 struct { 2177 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2178 u8 seq_len; 2179 } hw; 2180 }; 2181 }; 2182 2183 /** 2184 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2185 * 2186 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2187 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2188 * 2189 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2190 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2191 */ 2192 enum set_key_cmd { 2193 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2194 }; 2195 2196 /** 2197 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2198 * 2199 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2200 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2201 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2202 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2203 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2204 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2205 */ 2206 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2207 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2208 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2209 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2210 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2211 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2212 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2213 }; 2214 2215 /** 2216 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2217 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2218 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2219 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2220 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2221 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2222 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2223 * 2224 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2225 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2226 */ 2227 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2228 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2229 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2230 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2231 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2232 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2233 }; 2234 2235 /** 2236 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2237 * 2238 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2239 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2240 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2241 */ 2242 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2243 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2244 struct { 2245 s8 idx; 2246 u8 count; 2247 u8 count_cts; 2248 u8 count_rts; 2249 u16 flags; 2250 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2251 }; 2252 2253 /** 2254 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2255 * 2256 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2257 * 2258 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2259 * to the STA. 2260 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2261 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2262 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2263 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2264 * per peer TPC. 2265 */ 2266 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2267 s16 power; 2268 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2269 }; 2270 2271 /** 2272 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2273 * 2274 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2275 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2276 * 2277 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2278 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2279 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2280 * 2281 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2282 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2283 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2284 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2285 * 2286 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2287 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2288 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2289 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2290 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2291 */ 2292 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2293 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2294 2295 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2296 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2297 }; 2298 2299 /** 2300 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2301 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2302 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2303 * 2304 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2305 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2306 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2307 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2308 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2309 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2310 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2311 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2312 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2313 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2314 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2315 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2316 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation 2317 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2318 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2319 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2320 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2321 * the station moves to associated state. 2322 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2323 * 2324 */ 2325 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2326 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2327 2328 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2329 u8 link_id; 2330 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2331 2332 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2333 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2334 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2335 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2336 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2337 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2338 2339 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2340 2341 u8 rx_nss; 2342 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2343 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2344 }; 2345 2346 /** 2347 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2348 * 2349 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2350 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2351 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2352 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2353 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2354 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2355 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2356 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2357 * 2358 * @addr: MAC address 2359 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2360 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2361 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2362 * Can be modified by driver. 2363 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2364 * otherwise always false) 2365 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2366 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2367 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2368 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2369 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2370 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2371 * @rates: rate control selection table 2372 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2373 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2374 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2375 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2376 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2377 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2378 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2379 * unlimited. 2380 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2381 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2382 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2383 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2384 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2385 * is used for non-data frames 2386 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2387 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2388 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2389 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2390 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2391 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2392 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2393 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2394 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2395 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2396 * by the AP. 2397 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2398 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not. 2399 */ 2400 struct ieee80211_sta { 2401 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2402 u16 aid; 2403 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2404 bool wme; 2405 u8 uapsd_queues; 2406 u8 max_sp; 2407 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2408 bool tdls; 2409 bool tdls_initiator; 2410 bool mfp; 2411 bool mlo; 2412 bool spp_amsdu; 2413 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2414 2415 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2416 2417 bool support_p2p_ps; 2418 2419 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2420 2421 u16 valid_links; 2422 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2423 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2424 2425 /* must be last */ 2426 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2427 }; 2428 2429 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2430 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2431 #else 2432 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2433 { 2434 return true; 2435 } 2436 #endif 2437 2438 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2439 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2440 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2441 2442 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2443 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2444 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2445 2446 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2447 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2448 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2449 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2450 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id))) 2451 2452 /** 2453 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2454 * 2455 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2456 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2457 * 2458 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2459 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2460 */ 2461 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2462 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2463 }; 2464 2465 /** 2466 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2467 * 2468 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2469 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2470 */ 2471 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2472 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2473 }; 2474 2475 /** 2476 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2477 * 2478 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2479 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2480 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2481 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2482 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2483 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2484 * 2485 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2486 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2487 */ 2488 struct ieee80211_txq { 2489 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2490 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2491 u8 tid; 2492 u8 ac; 2493 2494 /* must be last */ 2495 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2496 }; 2497 2498 /** 2499 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2500 * 2501 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2502 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2503 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2504 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2505 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2506 * 2507 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2508 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2509 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2510 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2511 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2512 * algorithm. 2513 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2514 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2515 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2516 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2517 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2518 * CCK frames. 2519 * 2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2521 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2522 * the FCS at the end. 2523 * 2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2525 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2526 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2527 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2528 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2529 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2530 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2531 * 2532 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2533 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2534 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2535 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2536 * 2537 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2538 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2539 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2540 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2541 * 2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2543 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2544 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2545 * 2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2547 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2548 * 2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2550 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2551 * 2552 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2553 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2554 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2555 * 2556 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2557 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2558 * 2559 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2560 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2561 * 2562 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2563 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2564 * the stack. 2565 * 2566 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2567 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2568 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2569 * 2570 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2571 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2572 * dtim_period). 2573 * 2574 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2575 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2576 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2577 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2578 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2579 * only in that case. 2580 * 2581 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2582 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2583 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2584 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2585 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2586 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2587 * 2588 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2589 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2590 * software. 2591 * 2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2593 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2594 * active interfaces. 2595 * 2596 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2597 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2598 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2599 * 2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2601 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2602 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2603 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2604 * supported cipher suites. 2605 * 2606 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2607 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2608 * for frames. 2609 * 2610 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2611 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2612 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2613 * control for more details. 2614 * 2615 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2616 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2617 * 2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2619 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2620 * is supported. 2621 * 2622 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2623 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2624 * 2625 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2626 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2627 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2628 * 2629 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2630 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2631 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2632 * CSA frame. 2633 * 2634 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2635 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2636 * 2637 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2638 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2639 * 2640 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2641 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2642 * 2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2644 * within A-MPDU. 2645 * 2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2647 * for sent beacons. 2648 * 2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2650 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2651 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2652 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2653 * 2654 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2655 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2656 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2657 * timeout. 2658 * 2659 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2660 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2661 * 2662 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2663 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2664 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2665 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2666 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2667 * 2668 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2669 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2670 * 2671 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2672 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2673 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2674 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2675 * 2676 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2677 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2678 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2679 * 2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2681 * TDLS links. 2682 * 2683 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2684 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2685 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2686 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2687 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2688 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2689 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2690 * 2691 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2692 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2693 * 2694 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2695 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2696 * 2697 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2698 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2699 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2700 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2701 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2702 * 2703 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2704 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2705 * TXQs to start with. 2706 * 2707 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2708 * length in tx status information 2709 * 2710 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2711 * 2712 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2713 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2714 * 2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2716 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2717 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2718 * 2719 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2720 * offload 2721 * 2722 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2723 * offload 2724 * 2725 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2726 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2727 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2728 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2729 * the stack. 2730 * 2731 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2732 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2733 * 2734 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2735 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2736 * 2737 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT 2738 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead 2739 * 2740 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2741 */ 2742 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2743 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2744 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2745 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2746 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2747 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2748 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2749 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2750 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2751 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2752 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2753 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2754 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2755 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2756 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2757 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2758 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2759 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2760 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2761 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2762 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2763 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2764 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2765 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2766 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2767 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2768 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2769 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2770 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2771 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2772 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2773 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2774 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2775 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2776 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2777 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2778 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2779 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2780 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2781 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2782 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2783 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2784 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2785 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2786 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2787 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2788 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2789 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2790 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2791 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2792 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2793 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2794 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2795 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2796 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2797 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING, 2798 2799 /* keep last, obviously */ 2800 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2801 }; 2802 2803 /** 2804 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2805 * 2806 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2807 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2808 * 2809 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2810 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2811 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2812 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2813 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2814 * 2815 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2816 * 2817 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2818 * along with this structure. 2819 * 2820 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2821 * 2822 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2823 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2824 * 2825 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2826 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2827 * 2828 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2829 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2830 * 2831 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2832 * that HW supports 2833 * 2834 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2835 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2836 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2837 * 2838 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2839 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2840 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2841 * 2842 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2843 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2844 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2845 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2846 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2847 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2848 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2849 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2850 * 2851 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2852 * can handle. 2853 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2854 * the hw can report back. 2855 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2856 * 2857 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2858 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2859 * aggregation. 2860 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2861 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2862 * it shouldn't be set. 2863 * 2864 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2865 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2866 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2867 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2868 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2869 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2870 * 2871 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2872 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2873 * 2874 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2875 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2876 * 2877 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2878 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2879 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2880 * adding _BW is supported today. 2881 * 2882 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2883 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2884 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2885 * 2886 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2887 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2888 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2889 * device_timestamp. 2890 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2891 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2892 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2893 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2894 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2895 * 2896 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2897 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2898 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2899 * 2900 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2901 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2902 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2903 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2904 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2905 * neither enabled. 2906 * 2907 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2908 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2909 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2910 * 2911 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2912 * device. 2913 * 2914 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2915 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2916 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2917 * 2918 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2919 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2920 * 2921 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2922 * 2923 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2924 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2925 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2926 * 2927 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2928 */ 2929 struct ieee80211_hw { 2930 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2931 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2932 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2933 void *priv; 2934 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2935 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2936 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2937 int vif_data_size; 2938 int sta_data_size; 2939 int chanctx_data_size; 2940 int txq_data_size; 2941 u16 queues; 2942 u16 max_listen_interval; 2943 s8 max_signal; 2944 u8 max_rates; 2945 u8 max_report_rates; 2946 u8 max_rate_tries; 2947 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2948 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2949 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2950 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2951 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2952 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2953 struct { 2954 int units_pos; 2955 s16 accuracy; 2956 } radiotap_timestamp; 2957 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2958 u8 uapsd_queues; 2959 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2960 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2961 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2962 u8 weight_multiplier; 2963 u32 max_mtu; 2964 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2965 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2966 }; 2967 2968 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2969 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2970 { 2971 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2972 } 2973 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2974 2975 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2976 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2977 { 2978 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2979 } 2980 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2981 2982 /** 2983 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2984 * 2985 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2986 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2987 */ 2988 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2989 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2990 2991 /* Keep last */ 2992 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2993 }; 2994 2995 /** 2996 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2997 * 2998 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2999 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 3000 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 3001 * @status: channel-switch response status 3002 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 3003 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 3004 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 3005 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 3006 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 3007 */ 3008 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 3009 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3010 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 3011 u8 action_code; 3012 u32 status; 3013 u32 timestamp; 3014 u16 switch_time; 3015 u16 switch_timeout; 3016 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 3017 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 3018 }; 3019 3020 /** 3021 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 3022 * 3023 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 3024 * 3025 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 3026 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 3027 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 3028 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 3029 * is already used internally by mac80211. 3030 * 3031 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 3032 */ 3033 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 3034 3035 /** 3036 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 3037 * 3038 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 3039 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 3040 */ 3041 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 3042 { 3043 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 3044 } 3045 3046 /** 3047 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 3048 * 3049 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 3050 * @addr: the address to set 3051 */ 3052 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 3053 { 3054 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 3055 } 3056 3057 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3058 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3059 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3060 { 3061 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 3062 return NULL; 3063 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 3064 } 3065 3066 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3067 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3068 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3069 { 3070 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 3071 return NULL; 3072 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 3073 } 3074 3075 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3076 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3077 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3078 { 3079 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3080 return NULL; 3081 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3082 } 3083 3084 /** 3085 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3086 * @hw: the hardware 3087 * @skb: the skb 3088 * 3089 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3090 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3091 */ 3092 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3093 3094 /** 3095 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3096 * 3097 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3098 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3099 * 3100 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3101 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3102 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3103 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3104 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3105 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3106 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3107 * 3108 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3109 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3110 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3111 * 3112 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3113 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3114 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3115 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range. 3116 * 3117 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3118 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3119 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3120 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3121 * 3122 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3123 * 3124 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3125 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any 3126 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3127 * based on the receive flags. 3128 * 3129 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3130 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3131 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3132 * keys. 3133 * 3134 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3135 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3136 * handler. 3137 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3138 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3139 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3140 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3141 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3142 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3143 * 3144 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3145 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3146 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3147 * 3148 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3149 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3150 * requirements: 3151 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3152 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3153 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3154 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3155 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3156 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3157 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3158 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3159 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3160 */ 3161 3162 /** 3163 * DOC: Powersave support 3164 * 3165 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3166 * 3167 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself; 3168 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3169 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3170 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3171 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3172 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3173 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3174 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3175 * 3176 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3177 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3178 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3179 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3180 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3181 * 3182 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3183 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3184 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3185 * 3186 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3187 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3188 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3189 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3190 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3191 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3192 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3193 * 3194 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3195 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3196 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3197 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when 3198 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3199 * periods. 3200 * 3201 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3202 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3203 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3204 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3205 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3206 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3207 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3208 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3209 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3210 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3211 * 3212 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3213 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3214 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3215 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3216 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3217 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3218 * 3219 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3220 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3221 */ 3222 3223 /** 3224 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3225 * 3226 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3227 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3228 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3229 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3230 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3231 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3232 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3233 * 3234 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3235 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3236 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3237 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3238 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3239 * 3240 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3241 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3242 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3243 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3244 * 3245 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3246 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3247 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3248 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3249 * 3250 * - a list of information element IDs 3251 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3252 * 3253 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3254 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3255 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3256 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3257 * vendor information elements. 3258 * 3259 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3260 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3261 * 3262 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing 3263 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3264 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3265 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3266 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3267 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3268 * 3269 * 3270 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3271 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3272 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3273 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when 3274 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3275 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3276 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3277 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3278 * 3279 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3280 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3281 * signal strength threshold checking. 3282 */ 3283 3284 /** 3285 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3286 * 3287 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3288 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3289 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3290 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3291 * 3292 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3293 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3294 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3295 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3296 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3297 * hardware flags. 3298 * 3299 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3300 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3301 * turned off otherwise. 3302 * 3303 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3304 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3305 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3306 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3307 */ 3308 3309 /** 3310 * DOC: Frame filtering 3311 * 3312 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3313 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3314 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3315 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3316 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3317 * 3318 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3319 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3320 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3321 * 3322 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3323 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3324 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3325 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3326 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3327 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3328 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3329 * 3330 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3331 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3332 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3333 * or dropped. 3334 * 3335 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3336 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3337 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3338 * the flag, but not clear it. 3339 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3340 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3341 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3342 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3343 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3344 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3345 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3346 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3347 */ 3348 3349 /** 3350 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3351 * 3352 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3353 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3354 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3355 * 3356 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3357 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3358 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3359 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3360 * the driver code. 3361 * 3362 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3363 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3364 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3365 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3366 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3367 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3368 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3369 * 3370 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3371 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3372 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3373 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3374 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3375 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3376 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3377 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3378 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3379 * @sta_notify callback. 3380 * 3381 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3382 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3383 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3384 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3385 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3386 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3387 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3388 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3389 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3390 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3391 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3392 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3393 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3394 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3395 * 3396 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3397 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3398 * 3399 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3400 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3401 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3402 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3403 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3404 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3405 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3406 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3407 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3408 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3409 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3410 * 3411 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3412 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3413 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3414 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3415 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3416 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3417 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3418 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3419 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3420 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames. 3421 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3422 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3423 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3424 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3425 * 3426 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3427 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3428 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3429 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3430 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3431 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3432 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3433 * 3434 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3435 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3436 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3437 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3438 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3439 * 3440 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3441 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3442 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3443 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3444 */ 3445 3446 /** 3447 * DOC: HW queue control 3448 * 3449 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3450 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3451 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3452 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3453 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3454 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3455 * 3456 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3457 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3458 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3459 * 3460 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3461 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3462 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3463 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3464 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3465 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3466 * the hardware queue. 3467 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3468 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3469 * 3470 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual 3471 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3472 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3473 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3474 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3475 * 3476 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3477 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3478 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3479 * off-channel queue: 9 3480 * 3481 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3482 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3483 * 3484 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3485 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3486 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3487 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3488 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3489 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3490 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3491 * 3492 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3493 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3494 * 3495 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3496 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3497 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3498 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3499 */ 3500 3501 /** 3502 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3503 * 3504 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3505 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3506 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3507 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3508 * 3509 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3510 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3511 * multicast address. 3512 * 3513 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3514 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3515 * 3516 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3517 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3518 * 3519 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3520 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3521 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3522 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3523 * honour this flag if possible. 3524 * 3525 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3526 * station 3527 * 3528 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3529 * 3530 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3531 * 3532 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3533 * 3534 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3535 */ 3536 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3537 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3538 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3539 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3540 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3541 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3542 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3543 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3544 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3545 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3546 }; 3547 3548 /** 3549 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3550 * 3551 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3552 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3553 * 3554 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3555 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3556 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3557 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3558 * 3559 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3560 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3561 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3562 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3563 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3564 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3565 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3566 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3567 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3568 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3569 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3570 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3571 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3572 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3573 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3574 * session is gone and removes the station. 3575 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3576 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3577 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3578 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3579 */ 3580 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3581 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3582 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3583 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3584 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3585 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3586 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3587 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3588 }; 3589 3590 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3591 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3592 3593 /** 3594 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3595 * 3596 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3597 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3598 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3599 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3600 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3601 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3602 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3603 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3604 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3605 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3606 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3607 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3608 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3609 */ 3610 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3611 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3612 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3613 u16 tid; 3614 u16 ssn; 3615 u16 buf_size; 3616 bool amsdu; 3617 u16 timeout; 3618 }; 3619 3620 /** 3621 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3622 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3623 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3624 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3625 */ 3626 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3627 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3628 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3629 }; 3630 3631 /** 3632 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3633 * 3634 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3635 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3636 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3637 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3638 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3639 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3640 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3641 * the peer. 3642 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3643 * by the peer 3644 */ 3645 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3646 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3647 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3648 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3649 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3650 }; 3651 3652 /** 3653 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3654 * 3655 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3656 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3657 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3658 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3659 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3660 * 3661 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3662 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3663 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3664 */ 3665 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3666 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3667 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3668 }; 3669 3670 /** 3671 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3672 * 3673 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3674 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3675 * 3676 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3677 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3678 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3679 * of wowlan configuration) 3680 */ 3681 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3682 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3683 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3684 }; 3685 3686 /** 3687 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3688 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3689 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3690 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3691 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3692 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3693 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3694 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed. 3695 * Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3696 */ 3697 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3698 u16 duration; 3699 u16 subtype; 3700 u8 success:1; 3701 int link_id; 3702 }; 3703 3704 /** 3705 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3706 * 3707 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3708 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3709 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3710 * 3711 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3712 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3713 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3714 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3715 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3716 * Must be atomic. 3717 * 3718 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3719 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3720 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3721 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3722 * or zero. 3723 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3724 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3725 * is added. 3726 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3727 * 3728 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3729 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3730 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3731 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3732 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3733 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3734 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3735 * 3736 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3737 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3738 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3739 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3740 * reconfigured at resume time. 3741 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3742 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3743 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3744 * must return 1 from this function. 3745 * 3746 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3747 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3748 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3749 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3750 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3751 * 3752 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3753 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3754 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3755 * in suspend(). 3756 * 3757 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3758 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3759 * and @stop must be implemented. 3760 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3761 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3762 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3763 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3764 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3765 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3766 * 3767 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3768 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3769 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3770 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3771 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3772 * 3773 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3774 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3775 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3776 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3777 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3778 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3779 * MAC address of the device going away. 3780 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3781 * 3782 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3783 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3784 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3785 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3786 * 3787 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3788 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3789 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3790 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3791 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3792 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3793 * can sleep. 3794 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3795 * are not implemented. 3796 * 3797 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3798 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3799 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3800 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3801 * The callback can sleep. 3802 * 3803 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3804 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3805 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3806 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3807 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3808 * non-MLO connections. 3809 * The callback can sleep. 3810 * 3811 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3812 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3813 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3814 * 3815 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3816 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3817 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3818 * 3819 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3820 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3821 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3822 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3823 * which flags are changed. 3824 * This callback can sleep. 3825 * 3826 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3827 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3828 * 3829 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3830 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3831 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3832 * is enabled. 3833 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3834 * The callback can sleep. 3835 * 3836 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3837 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3838 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3839 * The callback must be atomic. 3840 * 3841 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3842 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3843 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3844 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3845 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3846 * 3847 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3848 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3849 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3850 * 3851 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3852 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3853 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3854 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3855 * that power save is disabled. 3856 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3857 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3858 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3859 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3860 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3861 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3862 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3863 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3864 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3865 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3866 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3867 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3868 * The callback can sleep. 3869 * 3870 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3871 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3872 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3873 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3874 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3875 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3876 * The callback can sleep. 3877 * 3878 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3879 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3880 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3881 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3882 * 3883 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3884 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3885 * 3886 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3887 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3888 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3889 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3890 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3891 * 3892 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3893 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3894 * this notification. 3895 * The callback can sleep. 3896 * 3897 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3898 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3899 * The callback can sleep. 3900 * 3901 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3902 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3903 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3904 * The callback must be atomic. 3905 * 3906 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3907 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3908 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3909 * should be set as well. 3910 * The callback can sleep. 3911 * 3912 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3913 * The callback can sleep. 3914 * 3915 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3916 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3917 * 3918 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3919 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3920 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3921 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3922 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3923 * This callback can sleep. 3924 * 3925 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif 3926 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a 3927 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3928 * 3929 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3930 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within 3931 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3932 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf 3933 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3934 * 3935 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3936 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3937 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3938 * callback can sleep. 3939 * 3940 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3941 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3942 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3943 * callback can sleep. 3944 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3945 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3946 * 3947 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3948 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3949 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3950 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3951 * 3952 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3953 * power for the station. 3954 * This callback can sleep. 3955 * 3956 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3957 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3958 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3959 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3960 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3961 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3962 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3963 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3964 * The callback can sleep. 3965 * 3966 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3967 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3968 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3969 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3970 * in @sta_state. 3971 * The callback can sleep. 3972 * 3973 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3974 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3975 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3976 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3977 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3978 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3979 * Must be atomic. 3980 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3981 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3982 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3983 * 3984 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3985 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3986 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3987 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3988 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3989 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3990 * The callback can sleep. 3991 * 3992 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3993 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3994 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3995 * The callback can sleep. 3996 * 3997 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3998 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3999 * required function. 4000 * The callback can sleep. 4001 * 4002 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 4003 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 4004 * required function. 4005 * The callback can sleep. 4006 * 4007 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 4008 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 4009 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 4010 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 4011 * The callback can sleep. 4012 * 4013 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 4014 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 4015 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 4016 * TSF synchronization. 4017 * The callback can sleep. 4018 * 4019 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 4020 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 4021 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 4022 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 4023 * The callback can sleep. 4024 * 4025 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 4026 * 4027 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 4028 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 4029 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 4030 * The callback can sleep. 4031 * 4032 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 4033 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 4034 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 4035 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 4036 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 4037 * 4038 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 4039 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 4040 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 4041 * 4042 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 4043 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 4044 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 4045 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 4046 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 4047 * Note that vif can be NULL. 4048 * The callback can sleep. 4049 * 4050 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for 4051 * the given station, as it's about to be removed. 4052 * The callback can sleep. 4053 * 4054 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 4055 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 4056 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 4057 * completion of the channel switch. 4058 * 4059 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4060 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4061 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4062 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4063 * 4064 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4065 * 4066 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 4067 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 4068 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 4069 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 4070 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 4071 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 4072 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 4073 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 4074 * must be accepted in this case. 4075 * This callback may sleep. 4076 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 4077 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 4078 * 4079 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 4080 * 4081 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 4082 * 4083 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 4084 * queues before entering power save. 4085 * 4086 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 4087 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 4088 * The callback can sleep. 4089 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 4090 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 4091 * The callback must be atomic. 4092 * 4093 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 4094 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4095 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4096 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4097 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4098 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4099 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4100 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4101 * more-data bit must always be set. 4102 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4103 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4104 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4105 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4106 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4107 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4108 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4109 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4110 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4111 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4112 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4113 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4114 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4115 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4116 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4117 * This callback must be atomic. 4118 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4119 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4120 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4121 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4122 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4123 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4124 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4125 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4126 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4127 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4128 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4129 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4130 * This callback must be atomic. 4131 * 4132 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4133 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's 4134 * expected to return a static value. 4135 * 4136 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4137 * 4138 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4139 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4140 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's 4141 * expected to return a static value. 4142 * 4143 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4144 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4145 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4146 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4147 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4148 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4149 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4150 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4151 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4152 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4153 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4154 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4155 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4156 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4157 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4158 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4159 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4160 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4161 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4162 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4163 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4164 * 4165 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4166 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4167 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4168 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4169 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4170 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4171 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4172 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4173 * 4174 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4175 * This callback may sleep. 4176 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4177 * This callback may sleep. 4178 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4179 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4180 * channel context with different settings 4181 * This callback may sleep. 4182 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4183 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4184 * This callback may sleep. 4185 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4186 * unbound from vif. 4187 * This callback may sleep. 4188 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4189 * another, as specified in the list of 4190 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4191 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4192 * This callback may sleep. 4193 * 4194 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4195 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4196 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4197 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4198 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4199 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4200 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4201 * 4202 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4203 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4204 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4205 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4206 * This callback may sleep. 4207 * 4208 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4209 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4210 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4211 * 4212 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4213 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4214 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4215 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4216 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4217 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4218 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4219 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4220 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4221 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4222 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4223 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4224 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4225 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4226 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4227 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4228 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4229 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4230 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4231 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4232 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4233 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4234 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4235 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4236 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4237 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4238 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4239 * 4240 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4241 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4242 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4243 * 4244 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4245 * and hardware limits. 4246 * 4247 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4248 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4249 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4250 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4251 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4252 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4253 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4254 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4255 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4256 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4257 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4258 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4259 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4260 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4261 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4262 * the function call. 4263 * 4264 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4265 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4266 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4267 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4268 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4269 * 4270 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4271 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4272 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4273 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4274 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4275 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4276 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4277 * changed parameters. 4278 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4279 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4280 * this call. 4281 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4282 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4283 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4284 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4285 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4286 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4287 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4288 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4289 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4290 * 4291 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4292 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4293 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4294 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4295 * This callback may sleep. 4296 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4297 * This callback may sleep. 4298 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4299 * 4-address mode 4300 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4301 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4302 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4303 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4304 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4305 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4306 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4307 * twt structure. 4308 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4309 * from the peer. 4310 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4311 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4312 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4313 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4314 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4315 * radar channel. 4316 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4317 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4318 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4319 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4320 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is 4321 * supported by the driver. 4322 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4323 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4324 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4325 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4326 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4327 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4328 * This callback can sleep. 4329 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4330 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4331 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4332 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4333 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4334 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is 4335 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of 4336 * that. 4337 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware 4338 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif. 4339 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid 4340 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown. 4341 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine 4342 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not. 4343 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and 4344 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping. 4345 */ 4346 struct ieee80211_ops { 4347 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4348 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4349 struct sk_buff *skb); 4350 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4351 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4352 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4353 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4354 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4355 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4356 #endif 4357 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4358 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4359 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4360 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4361 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4362 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4363 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4364 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4365 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4366 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4367 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4368 u64 changed); 4369 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4370 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4371 u64 changed); 4372 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4373 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4374 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4375 u64 changed); 4376 4377 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4378 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4379 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4380 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4381 4382 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4383 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4384 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4385 unsigned int changed_flags, 4386 unsigned int *total_flags, 4387 u64 multicast); 4388 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4389 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4390 unsigned int filter_flags, 4391 unsigned int changed_flags); 4392 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4393 bool set); 4394 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4395 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4396 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4397 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4399 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4400 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4401 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4402 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4403 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4404 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4405 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4406 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4407 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4408 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4409 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4410 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4411 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4412 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4413 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4414 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4415 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4416 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4417 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4418 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4419 const u8 *mac_addr); 4420 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4421 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4422 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4423 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4424 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4425 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4426 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4427 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4428 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4429 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4430 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4431 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4432 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4433 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4434 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4436 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4437 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4438 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4439 struct dentry *dir); 4440 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4441 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4442 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4443 struct dentry *dir); 4444 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4445 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4446 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4447 struct dentry *dir); 4448 #endif 4449 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4450 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4451 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4452 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4453 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4454 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4455 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4456 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4457 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4458 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4459 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4460 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4461 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4462 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4463 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4464 u32 changed); 4465 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4466 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4467 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4468 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4469 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4470 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4471 struct station_info *sinfo); 4472 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4473 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4474 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4475 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4476 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4477 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4478 u64 tsf); 4479 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4480 s64 offset); 4481 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4482 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4483 4484 /** 4485 * @ampdu_action: 4486 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4487 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4488 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4489 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4490 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4491 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4492 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4493 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4494 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4495 * 4496 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4497 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4498 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4499 * 4500 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4501 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4502 * 4503 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4504 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4505 * - ``TX: 81`` 4506 * 4507 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4508 * 4509 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4510 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4511 * if the session can start immediately. 4512 * 4513 * The callback can sleep. 4514 */ 4515 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4516 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4517 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4518 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4519 struct survey_info *survey); 4520 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4521 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4522 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4523 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4524 void *data, int len); 4525 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4526 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4527 void *data, int len); 4528 #endif 4529 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4530 u32 queues, bool drop); 4531 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4532 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4533 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4534 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4535 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4536 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4537 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4538 4539 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4540 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4541 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4542 int duration, 4543 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4544 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4545 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4546 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4547 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4548 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4549 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4550 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4551 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4552 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4553 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4554 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4555 4556 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4557 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4558 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4559 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4560 bool more_data); 4561 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4562 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4563 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4564 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4565 bool more_data); 4566 4567 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4568 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4569 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4571 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4572 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4573 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4574 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4575 4576 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4577 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4578 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4579 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4580 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4581 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4582 4583 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4584 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4585 unsigned int link_id); 4586 4587 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4588 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4589 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4590 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4591 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4592 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4593 u32 changed); 4594 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4595 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4596 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4597 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4598 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4599 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4600 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4601 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4602 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4603 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4604 int n_vifs, 4605 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4606 4607 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4608 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4609 4610 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4611 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4612 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4613 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4614 #endif 4615 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4616 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4617 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4618 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4619 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4620 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4621 4622 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4623 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4624 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4625 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4626 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4627 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4629 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4630 4631 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4632 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4633 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4634 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4635 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4636 int *dbm); 4637 4638 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4639 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4640 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4641 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4642 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4643 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4644 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4645 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4646 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4647 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4648 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4649 4650 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4651 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4652 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4653 4654 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4655 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4656 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4657 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4658 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4659 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4660 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4661 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4662 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4663 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4664 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4665 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4666 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4667 u8 instance_id); 4668 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4669 struct sk_buff *head, 4670 struct sk_buff *skb); 4671 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4672 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4673 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4674 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4675 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4676 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4677 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4678 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4679 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4680 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4681 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4682 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4683 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4684 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4685 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4686 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4687 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4688 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4689 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4690 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4691 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4692 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4693 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4694 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4695 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4696 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4697 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4698 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4699 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4700 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4701 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4702 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4703 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4704 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4705 struct net_device_path *path); 4706 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4707 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4708 u16 active_links); 4709 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4710 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4711 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4712 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4713 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4714 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4715 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4716 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4717 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4718 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4719 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4720 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4721 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4722 struct net_device *dev, 4723 enum tc_setup_type type, 4724 void *type_data); 4725 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res 4726 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4727 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm); 4728 }; 4729 4730 /** 4731 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4732 * 4733 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4734 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4735 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4736 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4737 * @priv_data_len. 4738 * 4739 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4740 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4741 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4742 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4743 * 4744 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4745 */ 4746 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4747 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4748 const char *requested_name); 4749 4750 /** 4751 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4752 * 4753 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4754 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4755 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4756 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4757 * @priv_data_len. 4758 * 4759 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4760 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4761 * 4762 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4763 */ 4764 static inline 4765 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4766 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4767 { 4768 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4769 } 4770 4771 /** 4772 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4773 * 4774 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4775 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4776 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4777 * 4778 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4779 * 4780 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4781 */ 4782 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4783 4784 /** 4785 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4786 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4787 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4788 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4789 */ 4790 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4791 int throughput; 4792 int blink_time; 4793 }; 4794 4795 /** 4796 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4797 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4798 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4799 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4800 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4801 */ 4802 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4803 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4804 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4805 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4806 }; 4807 4808 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4809 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4810 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4811 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4812 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4813 const char * 4814 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4815 unsigned int flags, 4816 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4817 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4818 #endif 4819 /** 4820 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4821 * 4822 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4823 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4824 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4825 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4826 * 4827 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4828 * 4829 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4830 */ 4831 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4832 { 4833 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4834 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4835 #else 4836 return NULL; 4837 #endif 4838 } 4839 4840 /** 4841 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4842 * 4843 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4844 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4845 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4846 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4847 * 4848 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4849 * 4850 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4851 */ 4852 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4853 { 4854 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4855 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4856 #else 4857 return NULL; 4858 #endif 4859 } 4860 4861 /** 4862 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4863 * 4864 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4865 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4866 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4867 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4868 * 4869 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4870 * 4871 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4872 */ 4873 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4874 { 4875 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4876 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4877 #else 4878 return NULL; 4879 #endif 4880 } 4881 4882 /** 4883 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4884 * 4885 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4886 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4887 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4888 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4889 * 4890 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4891 * 4892 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4893 */ 4894 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4895 { 4896 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4897 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4898 #else 4899 return NULL; 4900 #endif 4901 } 4902 4903 /** 4904 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4905 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4906 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4907 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4908 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4909 * 4910 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4911 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4912 * 4913 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4914 */ 4915 static inline const char * 4916 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4917 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4918 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4919 { 4920 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4921 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4922 blink_table_len); 4923 #else 4924 return NULL; 4925 #endif 4926 } 4927 4928 /** 4929 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4930 * 4931 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4932 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4933 * 4934 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4935 */ 4936 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4937 4938 /** 4939 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4940 * 4941 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4942 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4943 * before calling this function. 4944 * 4945 * @hw: the hardware to free 4946 */ 4947 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4948 4949 /** 4950 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4951 * 4952 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4953 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4954 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4955 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4956 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4957 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4958 * 4959 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4960 */ 4961 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4962 4963 /** 4964 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4965 * 4966 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4967 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4968 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4969 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4970 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4971 * 4972 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4973 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4974 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4975 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4976 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4977 * 4978 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4979 * 4980 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4981 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4982 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4983 * @list: the destination list 4984 */ 4985 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4986 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4987 4988 /** 4989 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4990 * 4991 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4992 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4993 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4994 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4995 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4996 * 4997 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4998 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4999 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 5000 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5001 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 5002 * 5003 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 5004 * 5005 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 5006 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 5007 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 5008 * @napi: the NAPI context 5009 */ 5010 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5011 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 5012 5013 /** 5014 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 5015 * 5016 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 5017 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 5018 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 5019 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 5020 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 5021 * 5022 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5023 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 5024 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 5025 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5026 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 5027 * 5028 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5029 * 5030 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 5031 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 5032 */ 5033 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 5034 { 5035 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 5036 } 5037 5038 /** 5039 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 5040 * 5041 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 5042 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5043 * 5044 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 5045 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 5046 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 5047 * 5048 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 5049 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 5050 */ 5051 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 5052 5053 /** 5054 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 5055 * 5056 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 5057 * (internally disables bottom halves). 5058 * 5059 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 5060 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5061 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 5062 * 5063 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 5064 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 5065 */ 5066 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5067 struct sk_buff *skb) 5068 { 5069 local_bh_disable(); 5070 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 5071 local_bh_enable(); 5072 } 5073 5074 /** 5075 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 5076 * 5077 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 5078 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 5079 * entering/leaving PS mode. 5080 * 5081 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 5082 * 5083 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 5084 * each other. 5085 * 5086 * @sta: currently connected sta 5087 * @start: start or stop PS 5088 * 5089 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 5090 */ 5091 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 5092 5093 /** 5094 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 5095 * (in process context) 5096 * 5097 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 5098 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 5099 * applies. 5100 * 5101 * @sta: currently connected sta 5102 * @start: start or stop PS 5103 * 5104 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 5105 */ 5106 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5107 bool start) 5108 { 5109 int ret; 5110 5111 local_bh_disable(); 5112 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 5113 local_bh_enable(); 5114 5115 return ret; 5116 } 5117 5118 /** 5119 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 5120 * @sta: currently connected station 5121 * 5122 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5123 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 5124 * connected station was received. 5125 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5126 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 5127 * be serialized. 5128 */ 5129 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 5130 5131 /** 5132 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 5133 * @sta: currently connected station 5134 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 5135 * 5136 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5137 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5138 * from a connected station was received. 5139 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5140 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5141 * serialized. 5142 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5143 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5144 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5145 * checks. 5146 */ 5147 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5148 5149 /* 5150 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5151 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5152 */ 5153 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5154 5155 /** 5156 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5157 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5158 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5159 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5160 * 5161 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5162 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5163 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5164 * 5165 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5166 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5167 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5168 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5169 * 5170 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5171 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5172 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5173 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5174 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5175 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5176 * 5177 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5178 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5179 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5180 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5181 * use this API. 5182 */ 5183 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5184 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5185 5186 /** 5187 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5188 * 5189 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5190 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5191 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5192 * 5193 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5194 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5195 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5196 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5197 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5198 */ 5199 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5200 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5201 struct sk_buff *skb, 5202 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5203 int max_rates); 5204 5205 /** 5206 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5207 * 5208 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5209 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5210 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5211 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5212 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5213 * slow stations to starve). 5214 * 5215 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5216 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5217 */ 5218 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5219 u32 thr); 5220 5221 /** 5222 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5223 * 5224 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5225 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5226 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5227 * 5228 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5229 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5230 * @info: tx status information 5231 */ 5232 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5233 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5234 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5235 5236 /** 5237 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback 5238 * 5239 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5240 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5241 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5242 * 5243 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5244 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5245 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5246 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5247 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5248 * 5249 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5250 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5251 */ 5252 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5253 struct sk_buff *skb); 5254 5255 /** 5256 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5257 * 5258 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb() 5259 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5260 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5261 * 5262 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5263 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5264 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5265 * 5266 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5267 * @status: tx status information 5268 */ 5269 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5270 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5271 5272 /** 5273 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5274 * 5275 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb() 5276 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5277 * specific skbs. 5278 * 5279 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5280 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5281 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5282 * 5283 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5284 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5285 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5286 * @info: tx status information 5287 */ 5288 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5289 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5290 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5291 { 5292 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5293 .sta = sta, 5294 .info = info, 5295 }; 5296 5297 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5298 } 5299 5300 /** 5301 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5302 * 5303 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context. 5304 * 5305 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and 5306 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5307 * for a single hardware. 5308 * 5309 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5310 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5311 */ 5312 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5313 struct sk_buff *skb) 5314 { 5315 local_bh_disable(); 5316 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb); 5317 local_bh_enable(); 5318 } 5319 5320 /** 5321 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5322 * 5323 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context 5324 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5325 * 5326 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and 5327 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5328 * 5329 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5330 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5331 */ 5332 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5333 struct sk_buff *skb); 5334 5335 /** 5336 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5337 * 5338 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5339 * connected STA. 5340 * 5341 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5342 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5343 */ 5344 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5345 5346 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5347 5348 /** 5349 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5350 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5351 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5352 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5353 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5354 * should be ignored. 5355 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5356 */ 5357 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5358 u16 tim_offset; 5359 u16 tim_length; 5360 5361 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5362 u16 mbssid_off; 5363 }; 5364 5365 /** 5366 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5367 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5368 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5369 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5370 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5371 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5372 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5373 * 5374 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5375 * obtain the beacon template. 5376 * 5377 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5378 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5379 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5380 * applicable, the CSA count. 5381 * 5382 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5383 * 5384 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5385 */ 5386 struct sk_buff * 5387 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5388 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5389 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5390 unsigned int link_id); 5391 5392 /** 5393 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation 5394 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5395 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5396 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5397 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5398 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP). 5399 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set. 5400 * 5401 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5402 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the 5403 * requested index. 5404 * 5405 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates. 5406 */ 5407 struct sk_buff * 5408 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5409 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5410 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5411 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index); 5412 5413 /** 5414 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons 5415 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons. 5416 * 5417 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons. 5418 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon 5419 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5420 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5421 */ 5422 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons { 5423 u8 cnt; 5424 struct { 5425 struct sk_buff *skb; 5426 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs; 5427 } bcn[]; 5428 }; 5429 5430 /** 5431 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation 5432 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5433 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5434 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5435 * 5436 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5437 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required 5438 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only 5439 * one multiple BSSID element. 5440 * 5441 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory. 5442 * 5443 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *. 5444 * %NULL on error. 5445 */ 5446 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons * 5447 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5448 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5449 unsigned int link_id); 5450 5451 /** 5452 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list 5453 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers. 5454 * 5455 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling 5456 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list() 5457 */ 5458 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons); 5459 5460 /** 5461 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5462 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5463 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5464 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5465 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5466 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5467 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5468 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5469 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5470 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5471 * 5472 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5473 * obtain the beacon frame. 5474 * 5475 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5476 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5477 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5478 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5479 * 5480 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5481 * 5482 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5483 */ 5484 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5485 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5486 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5487 unsigned int link_id); 5488 5489 /** 5490 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5491 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5492 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5493 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5494 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5495 * 5496 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5497 * 5498 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5499 */ 5500 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5501 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5502 unsigned int link_id) 5503 { 5504 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5505 } 5506 5507 /** 5508 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5509 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5510 * 5511 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5512 * This function is called implicitly when 5513 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5514 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5515 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5516 * 5517 * Return: new countdown value 5518 */ 5519 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5520 5521 /** 5522 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5523 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5524 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5525 * 5526 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5527 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5528 * 5529 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5530 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5531 */ 5532 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5533 5534 /** 5535 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5536 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5537 * 5538 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5539 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5540 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5541 */ 5542 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5543 5544 /** 5545 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5546 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5547 * 5548 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5549 */ 5550 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5551 5552 /** 5553 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5554 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5555 * 5556 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5557 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5558 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5559 */ 5560 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5561 5562 /** 5563 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5564 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5565 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5566 * 5567 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5568 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5569 * 5570 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5571 * 5572 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5573 */ 5574 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5575 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5576 5577 /** 5578 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5579 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5580 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5581 * 5582 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5583 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5584 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5585 * 5586 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5587 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5588 * 5589 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5590 */ 5591 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5592 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5593 5594 /** 5595 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5596 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5597 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5598 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5599 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5600 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5601 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5602 * if at all possible 5603 * 5604 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5605 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5606 * BSSID and address is used. 5607 * 5608 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5609 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5610 * 5611 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5612 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5613 * 5614 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5615 */ 5616 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5617 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5618 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5619 5620 /** 5621 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5622 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5623 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5624 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5625 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5626 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5627 * 5628 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5629 * hardware. 5630 * 5631 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5632 */ 5633 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5634 const u8 *src_addr, 5635 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5636 size_t tailroom); 5637 5638 /** 5639 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5640 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5641 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5642 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5643 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5644 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5645 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5646 * 5647 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5648 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5649 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5650 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5651 */ 5652 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5653 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5654 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5655 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5656 5657 /** 5658 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5659 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5660 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5661 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5662 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5663 * 5664 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5665 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5666 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5667 * 5668 * Return: The duration. 5669 */ 5670 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5671 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5672 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5673 5674 /** 5675 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5676 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5677 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5678 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5679 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5680 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5681 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5682 * 5683 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5684 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5685 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5686 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5687 */ 5688 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5689 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5690 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5691 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5692 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5693 5694 /** 5695 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5696 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5697 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5698 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5699 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5700 * 5701 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5702 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5703 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5704 * 5705 * Return: The duration. 5706 */ 5707 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5708 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5709 size_t frame_len, 5710 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5711 5712 /** 5713 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5714 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5715 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5716 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5717 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5718 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5719 * 5720 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5721 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5722 * 5723 * Return: The duration. 5724 */ 5725 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5726 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5727 enum nl80211_band band, 5728 size_t frame_len, 5729 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5730 5731 /** 5732 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5733 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5734 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5735 * 5736 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5737 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5738 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5739 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5740 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5741 * 5742 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5743 * frames are available. 5744 * 5745 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5746 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5747 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5748 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5749 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5750 * use common code for all beacons. 5751 */ 5752 struct sk_buff * 5753 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5754 5755 /** 5756 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5757 * 5758 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5759 * 5760 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5761 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5762 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5763 */ 5764 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5765 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5766 5767 /** 5768 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5769 * 5770 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5771 * from the given packet. 5772 * 5773 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5774 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5775 * with this P1K 5776 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5777 */ 5778 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5779 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5780 { 5781 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5782 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5783 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5784 5785 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5786 } 5787 5788 /** 5789 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5790 * 5791 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5792 * and transmitter address. 5793 * 5794 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5795 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5796 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5797 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5798 */ 5799 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5800 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5801 5802 /** 5803 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5804 * 5805 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5806 * in the packet. 5807 * 5808 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5809 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5810 * encrypted with this key 5811 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5812 */ 5813 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5814 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5815 5816 /** 5817 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5818 * 5819 * @pos: start of crypto header 5820 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5821 * @pn: PN to add 5822 * 5823 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5824 * the packet payload) 5825 * 5826 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5827 * point to the crypto header) 5828 */ 5829 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5830 5831 /** 5832 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5833 * 5834 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5835 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5836 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5837 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5838 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5839 * 5840 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5841 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5842 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5843 * 5844 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5845 * can be done concurrently. 5846 */ 5847 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5848 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5849 5850 /** 5851 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5852 * 5853 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5854 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5855 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5856 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5857 * @seq: new sequence data 5858 * 5859 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5860 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5861 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5862 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5863 * 5864 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5865 * can be done concurrently. 5866 */ 5867 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5868 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5869 5870 /** 5871 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5872 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5873 * 5874 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held. 5875 * 5876 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5877 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5878 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5879 */ 5880 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5881 5882 /** 5883 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5884 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5885 * @keyconf: new key data 5886 * 5887 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5888 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5889 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5890 * 5891 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5892 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5893 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5894 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5895 * 5896 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5897 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5898 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5899 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5900 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5901 * of the reconfiguration. 5902 * 5903 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5904 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5905 * 5906 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5907 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5908 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5909 * the key that's being replaced. 5910 */ 5911 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5912 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5913 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5914 5915 /** 5916 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5917 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5918 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5919 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5920 * @gfp: allocation flags 5921 */ 5922 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5923 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5924 5925 /** 5926 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5927 * 5928 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5929 * at the same time. 5930 * 5931 * @keyconf: the key in question 5932 */ 5933 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5934 5935 /** 5936 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5937 * 5938 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5939 * at the same time. 5940 * 5941 * @keyconf: the key in question 5942 */ 5943 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5944 5945 /** 5946 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5947 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5948 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5949 * 5950 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5951 */ 5952 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5953 5954 /** 5955 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5956 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5957 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5958 * 5959 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5960 */ 5961 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5962 5963 /** 5964 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5965 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5966 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5967 * 5968 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5969 * 5970 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5971 */ 5972 5973 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5974 5975 /** 5976 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5977 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5978 * 5979 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5980 */ 5981 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5982 5983 /** 5984 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5985 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5986 * 5987 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5988 */ 5989 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5990 5991 /** 5992 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5993 * 5994 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5995 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5996 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5997 * any context, including hardirq context. 5998 * 5999 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 6000 * @info: information about the completed scan 6001 */ 6002 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6003 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6004 6005 /** 6006 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 6007 * 6008 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 6009 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 6010 * 6011 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 6012 */ 6013 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6014 6015 /** 6016 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 6017 * 6018 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 6019 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 6020 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 6021 * while associating, for instance. 6022 * 6023 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 6024 */ 6025 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6026 6027 /** 6028 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 6029 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 6030 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 6031 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 6032 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 6033 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 6034 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 6035 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 6036 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 6037 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 6038 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 6039 * for instance. 6040 */ 6041 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 6042 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 6043 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 6044 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 6045 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 6046 }; 6047 6048 /** 6049 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 6050 * 6051 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6052 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 6053 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 6054 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6055 * 6056 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6057 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6058 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 6059 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6060 */ 6061 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 6062 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 6063 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6064 void *data); 6065 6066 /** 6067 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 6068 * 6069 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6070 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6071 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 6072 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 6073 * be used. 6074 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6075 * 6076 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6077 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6078 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 6079 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6080 */ 6081 static inline void 6082 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 6083 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 6084 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6085 void *data) 6086 { 6087 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 6088 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 6089 iterator, data); 6090 } 6091 6092 /** 6093 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 6094 * 6095 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6096 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6097 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6098 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 6099 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6100 * 6101 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6102 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6103 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6104 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6105 */ 6106 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6107 u32 iter_flags, 6108 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6109 u8 *mac, 6110 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6111 void *data); 6112 6113 /** 6114 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 6115 * 6116 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6117 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6118 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 6119 * 6120 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6121 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6122 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6123 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6124 */ 6125 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6126 u32 iter_flags, 6127 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6128 u8 *mac, 6129 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6130 void *data); 6131 6132 /** 6133 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 6134 * 6135 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6136 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6137 * function for them. 6138 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6139 * 6140 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6141 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6142 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6143 */ 6144 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6145 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6146 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6147 void *data); 6148 /** 6149 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6150 * 6151 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 6152 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 6153 * 6154 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6155 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 6156 */ 6157 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 6158 6159 /** 6160 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6161 * 6162 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 6163 * workqueue. 6164 * 6165 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6166 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 6167 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6168 */ 6169 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6170 struct delayed_work *dwork, 6171 unsigned long delay); 6172 6173 /** 6174 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer. 6175 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6176 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6177 * 6178 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer 6179 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the 6180 * mac80211. 6181 * 6182 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section. 6183 */ 6184 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6185 u16 tid); 6186 6187 /** 6188 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 6189 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6190 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6191 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 6192 * 6193 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 6194 * 6195 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6196 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6197 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6198 */ 6199 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6200 u16 timeout); 6201 6202 /** 6203 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6204 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6205 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6206 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6207 * 6208 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6209 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6210 * from any context. 6211 */ 6212 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6213 u16 tid); 6214 6215 /** 6216 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6217 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6218 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6219 * 6220 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6221 * 6222 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6223 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6224 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6225 */ 6226 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6227 6228 /** 6229 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6230 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6231 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6232 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6233 * 6234 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6235 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6236 * can be called from any context. 6237 */ 6238 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6239 u16 tid); 6240 6241 /** 6242 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6243 * 6244 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6245 * @addr: station's address 6246 * 6247 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6248 * 6249 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6250 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6251 */ 6252 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6253 const u8 *addr); 6254 6255 /** 6256 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6257 * 6258 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6259 * @addr: remote station's address 6260 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6261 * 6262 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6263 * 6264 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6265 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6266 * 6267 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6268 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6269 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6270 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6271 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6272 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6273 * is not reliable. 6274 * 6275 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6276 */ 6277 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6278 const u8 *addr, 6279 const u8 *localaddr); 6280 6281 /** 6282 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6283 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6284 * @addr: remote station's link address 6285 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6286 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6287 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6288 * 6289 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6290 */ 6291 struct ieee80211_sta * 6292 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6293 const u8 *addr, 6294 const u8 *localaddr, 6295 unsigned int *link_id); 6296 6297 /** 6298 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6299 * @hw: the hardware 6300 * @pubsta: the station 6301 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6302 * 6303 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6304 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6305 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6306 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6307 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6308 * 6309 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6310 * manner. 6311 * 6312 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6313 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6314 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6315 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6316 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6317 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6318 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6319 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6320 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6321 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6322 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6323 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6324 * woke up while blocked or not. 6325 */ 6326 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6327 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6328 6329 /** 6330 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6331 * @pubsta: the station 6332 * 6333 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6334 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6335 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6336 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6337 * 6338 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6339 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6340 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6341 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6342 * 6343 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6344 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6345 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6346 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6347 */ 6348 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6349 6350 /** 6351 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6352 * @pubsta: the station 6353 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6354 * 6355 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6356 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6357 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6358 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6359 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6360 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6361 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6362 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6363 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6364 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6365 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6366 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6367 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6368 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6369 */ 6370 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6371 6372 /** 6373 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6374 * @pubsta: the station 6375 * 6376 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6377 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6378 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6379 * 6380 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6381 * there is no need to call this function. 6382 */ 6383 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6384 6385 /** 6386 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6387 * 6388 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6389 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6390 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6391 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6392 * 6393 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6394 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6395 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6396 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6397 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6398 * attempts. 6399 * 6400 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6401 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6402 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6403 * them to 0. 6404 * 6405 * @pubsta: the station 6406 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6407 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6408 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6409 */ 6410 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6411 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6412 6413 /** 6414 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6415 * 6416 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6417 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6418 * 6419 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6420 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6421 */ 6422 bool 6423 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6424 6425 /** 6426 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6427 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6428 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6429 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6430 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6431 * 6432 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep. 6433 * 6434 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6435 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6436 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6437 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. 6438 * 6439 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6440 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6441 * set_key callback. 6442 */ 6443 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6444 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6445 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6446 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6447 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6448 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6449 void *data), 6450 void *iter_data); 6451 6452 /** 6453 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6454 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6455 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6456 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6457 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6458 * 6459 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6460 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6461 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6462 * in removal process will be skipped. 6463 * 6464 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6465 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6466 */ 6467 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6468 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6469 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6470 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6471 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6472 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6473 void *data), 6474 void *iter_data); 6475 6476 /** 6477 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6478 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6479 * @iter: iterator function 6480 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6481 * 6482 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6483 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6484 * places while calling into the driver. 6485 * 6486 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6487 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6488 * removed. 6489 * 6490 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6491 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6492 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6493 * or not. 6494 */ 6495 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6496 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6497 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6498 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6499 void *data), 6500 void *iter_data); 6501 6502 /** 6503 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6504 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6505 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6506 * 6507 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6508 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6509 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6510 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6511 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6512 * %NULL. 6513 * 6514 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6515 */ 6516 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6517 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6518 6519 /** 6520 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6521 * 6522 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6523 * 6524 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6525 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6526 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6527 */ 6528 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6529 6530 /** 6531 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6532 * 6533 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6534 * 6535 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6536 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6537 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6538 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6539 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6540 * 6541 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6542 * without connection recovery attempts. 6543 */ 6544 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6545 6546 /** 6547 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6548 * 6549 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6550 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6551 * 6552 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6553 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6554 */ 6555 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6556 6557 /** 6558 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6559 * 6560 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6561 * 6562 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6563 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6564 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6565 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6566 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6567 * 6568 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6569 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6570 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6571 * disconnect normally later. 6572 * 6573 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6574 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6575 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6576 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6577 */ 6578 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6579 6580 /** 6581 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6582 * hardware restart 6583 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6584 * 6585 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6586 * hardware restart. 6587 */ 6588 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6589 6590 /** 6591 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6592 * rssi threshold triggered 6593 * 6594 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6595 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6596 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6597 * @gfp: context flags 6598 * 6599 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6600 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6601 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6602 */ 6603 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6604 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6605 s32 rssi_level, 6606 gfp_t gfp); 6607 6608 /** 6609 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6610 * 6611 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6612 * @gfp: context flags 6613 */ 6614 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6615 6616 /** 6617 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6618 * 6619 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6620 */ 6621 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6622 6623 /** 6624 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6625 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6626 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6627 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is 6628 * false. 6629 * 6630 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6631 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6632 */ 6633 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success, 6634 unsigned int link_id); 6635 6636 /** 6637 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6638 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6639 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6640 * 6641 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6642 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6643 * a deauth frame in this case. 6644 */ 6645 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6646 bool block_tx); 6647 6648 /** 6649 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6650 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6651 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6652 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6653 * 6654 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6655 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6656 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6657 */ 6658 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6659 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6660 6661 /** 6662 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6663 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6664 */ 6665 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6666 6667 /** 6668 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6669 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6670 */ 6671 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6672 6673 /** 6674 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6675 * 6676 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6677 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6678 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6679 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6680 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6681 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6682 * 6683 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6684 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6685 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6686 */ 6687 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6688 const u8 *addr); 6689 6690 /** 6691 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6692 * @pubsta: station struct 6693 * @tid: the session's TID 6694 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6695 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6696 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6697 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6698 * 6699 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6700 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6701 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6702 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6703 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames) 6704 */ 6705 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6706 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6707 u16 received_mpdus); 6708 6709 /** 6710 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6711 * 6712 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6713 * buffer. 6714 * 6715 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6716 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6717 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6718 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6719 */ 6720 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6721 6722 /** 6723 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6724 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6725 * @addr: station mac address 6726 * @tid: the rx tid 6727 */ 6728 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6729 unsigned int tid); 6730 6731 /** 6732 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6733 * 6734 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6735 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6736 * reordering. 6737 * 6738 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6739 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6740 * 6741 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6742 * @addr: station mac address 6743 * @tid: the rx tid 6744 */ 6745 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6746 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6747 { 6748 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6749 return; 6750 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6751 } 6752 6753 /** 6754 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6755 * 6756 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6757 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6758 * reordering. 6759 * 6760 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6761 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6762 * 6763 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6764 * @addr: station mac address 6765 * @tid: the rx tid 6766 */ 6767 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6768 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6769 { 6770 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6771 return; 6772 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6773 } 6774 6775 /** 6776 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6777 * 6778 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6779 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6780 * 6781 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6782 * 6783 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6784 * @addr: station mac address 6785 * @tid: the rx tid 6786 */ 6787 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6788 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6789 6790 /* Rate control API */ 6791 6792 /** 6793 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6794 * 6795 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6796 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6797 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6798 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6799 * to be filled in 6800 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6801 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6802 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6803 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6804 * RTS threshold 6805 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6806 * if the selected rate supports it 6807 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6808 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6809 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6810 */ 6811 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6812 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6813 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6814 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6815 struct sk_buff *skb; 6816 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6817 bool rts, short_preamble; 6818 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6819 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6820 bool bss; 6821 }; 6822 6823 /** 6824 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6825 */ 6826 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6827 /** 6828 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6829 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6830 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6831 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6832 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6833 */ 6834 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6835 /** 6836 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6837 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6838 */ 6839 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6840 }; 6841 6842 struct rate_control_ops { 6843 unsigned long capa; 6844 const char *name; 6845 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6846 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6847 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6848 void (*free)(void *priv); 6849 6850 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6851 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6852 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6853 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6854 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6855 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6856 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6857 u32 changed); 6858 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6859 void *priv_sta); 6860 6861 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6862 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6863 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6864 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6865 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6866 struct sk_buff *skb); 6867 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6868 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6869 6870 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6871 struct dentry *dir); 6872 6873 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6874 }; 6875 6876 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6877 enum nl80211_band band, 6878 int index) 6879 { 6880 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6881 } 6882 6883 static inline s8 6884 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6885 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6886 { 6887 int i; 6888 6889 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6890 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6891 return i; 6892 6893 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6894 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6895 6896 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6897 return 0; 6898 } 6899 6900 static inline 6901 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6902 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6903 { 6904 unsigned int i; 6905 6906 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6907 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6908 return true; 6909 return false; 6910 } 6911 6912 /** 6913 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6914 * 6915 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6916 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6917 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6918 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6919 * 6920 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6921 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6922 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6923 */ 6924 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6925 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6926 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6927 6928 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6929 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6930 6931 static inline bool 6932 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6933 { 6934 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6935 } 6936 6937 static inline bool 6938 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6939 { 6940 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6941 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6942 } 6943 6944 static inline bool 6945 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6946 { 6947 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6948 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6949 } 6950 6951 static inline bool 6952 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6953 { 6954 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6955 } 6956 6957 static inline bool 6958 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6959 { 6960 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6961 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6962 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6963 } 6964 6965 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6966 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6967 { 6968 if (p2p) { 6969 switch (type) { 6970 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6971 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6972 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6973 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6974 default: 6975 break; 6976 } 6977 } 6978 return type; 6979 } 6980 6981 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6982 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6983 { 6984 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6985 } 6986 6987 /** 6988 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif 6989 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6990 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6991 * 6992 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found 6993 */ 6994 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 6995 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6996 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6997 { 6998 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6999 } 7000 7001 /** 7002 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 7003 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 7004 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 7005 * 7006 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 7007 */ 7008 static inline __le16 7009 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 7010 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 7011 { 7012 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 7013 } 7014 7015 /** 7016 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif 7017 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 7018 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 7019 * 7020 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found 7021 */ 7022 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 7023 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 7024 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 7025 { 7026 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 7027 } 7028 7029 /** 7030 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 7031 * 7032 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 7033 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 7034 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 7035 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 7036 * 7037 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 7038 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 7039 * matching GroupId management frame. 7040 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 7041 */ 7042 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 7043 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 7044 7045 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7046 int rssi_min_thold, 7047 int rssi_max_thold); 7048 7049 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7050 7051 /** 7052 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 7053 * 7054 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 7055 * 7056 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 7057 * 7058 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 7059 * applicable. 7060 */ 7061 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7062 7063 /** 7064 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 7065 * @vif: virtual interface 7066 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 7067 * @gfp: allocation flags 7068 * 7069 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 7070 */ 7071 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7072 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7073 gfp_t gfp); 7074 7075 /** 7076 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 7077 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7078 * @vif: virtual interface 7079 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 7080 * @band: the band to transmit on 7081 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 7082 * 7083 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 7084 */ 7085 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7086 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 7087 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 7088 7089 /** 7090 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 7091 * of injected frames. 7092 * 7093 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 7094 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 7095 * of the skb before calling this function. 7096 * 7097 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 7098 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 7099 */ 7100 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 7101 struct net_device *dev); 7102 7103 /** 7104 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 7105 * 7106 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 7107 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 7108 * 7109 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 7110 * 7111 * private: 7112 * 7113 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 7114 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 7115 */ 7116 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 7117 u32 next_tsf; 7118 bool has_next_tsf; 7119 7120 u8 absent; 7121 7122 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7123 struct { 7124 u32 start; 7125 u32 duration; 7126 u32 interval; 7127 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7128 }; 7129 7130 /** 7131 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 7132 * 7133 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 7134 * @data: NoA tracking data 7135 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7136 * 7137 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 7138 */ 7139 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 7140 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7141 7142 /** 7143 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 7144 * 7145 * @data: NoA tracking data 7146 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7147 */ 7148 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7149 7150 /** 7151 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 7152 * @vif: virtual interface 7153 * @peer: the peer's destination address 7154 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 7155 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 7156 * @gfp: allocation flags 7157 * 7158 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 7159 */ 7160 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 7161 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7162 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7163 7164 /** 7165 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 7166 * 7167 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 7168 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 7169 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 7170 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 7171 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 7172 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 7173 * 7174 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 7175 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 7176 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7177 * 7178 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 7179 * @tid: the TID to reserve 7180 * 7181 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 7182 */ 7183 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7184 7185 /** 7186 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 7187 * 7188 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 7189 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 7190 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 7191 * 7192 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 7193 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 7194 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7195 * 7196 * @sta: the station 7197 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 7198 */ 7199 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7200 7201 /** 7202 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7203 * 7204 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7205 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7206 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7207 * 7208 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 7209 * 7210 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 7211 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 7212 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 7213 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 7214 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 7215 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 7216 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 7217 * 7218 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 7219 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 7220 */ 7221 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7222 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7223 7224 /** 7225 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7226 * (in process context) 7227 * 7228 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 7229 * (internally disables bottom halves). 7230 * 7231 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7232 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7233 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7234 */ 7235 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7236 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7237 { 7238 struct sk_buff *skb; 7239 7240 local_bh_disable(); 7241 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 7242 local_bh_enable(); 7243 7244 return skb; 7245 } 7246 7247 /** 7248 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7249 * 7250 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7251 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7252 * 7253 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7254 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7255 */ 7256 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7257 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7258 7259 /** 7260 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7261 * 7262 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7263 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7264 * 7265 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7266 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7267 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7268 */ 7269 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7270 7271 /** 7272 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7273 * 7274 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7275 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7276 * 7277 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7278 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7279 */ 7280 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7281 7282 /* (deprecated) */ 7283 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7284 { 7285 } 7286 7287 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7288 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7289 7290 /** 7291 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7292 * 7293 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7294 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7295 * 7296 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7297 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7298 * 7299 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7300 * this TXQ internally. 7301 */ 7302 static inline void 7303 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7304 { 7305 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7306 } 7307 7308 /** 7309 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7310 * 7311 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7312 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7313 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7314 * 7315 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7316 * internally. 7317 */ 7318 static inline void 7319 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7320 bool force) 7321 { 7322 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7323 } 7324 7325 /** 7326 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7327 * 7328 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7329 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7330 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by 7331 * next_txq(). 7332 * 7333 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7334 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7335 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7336 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7337 * again. 7338 * 7339 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7340 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7341 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7342 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7343 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7344 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7345 * 7346 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7347 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7348 */ 7349 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7350 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7351 7352 /** 7353 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7354 * 7355 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7356 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7357 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7358 * 7359 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7360 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7361 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7362 */ 7363 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7364 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7365 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7366 7367 /** 7368 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7369 * 7370 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7371 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7372 * 7373 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7374 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7375 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7376 * @gfp: allocation flags 7377 */ 7378 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7379 u8 inst_id, 7380 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7381 gfp_t gfp); 7382 7383 /** 7384 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7385 * 7386 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7387 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7388 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7389 * 7390 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7391 * @match: match event information 7392 * @gfp: allocation flags 7393 */ 7394 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7395 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7396 gfp_t gfp); 7397 7398 /** 7399 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7400 * 7401 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7402 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7403 * 7404 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7405 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7406 * information. 7407 * @len: frame length in bytes 7408 */ 7409 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7410 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7411 int len); 7412 7413 /** 7414 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7415 * 7416 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7417 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7418 * 7419 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7420 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7421 * @len: frame length in bytes 7422 */ 7423 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7424 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7425 int len); 7426 /** 7427 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7428 * 7429 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7430 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7431 * hardware or firmware. 7432 * 7433 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7434 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7435 */ 7436 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7437 7438 /** 7439 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7440 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7441 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7442 * 7443 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7444 * 7445 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7446 */ 7447 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7448 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7449 7450 /** 7451 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7452 * probe response template. 7453 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7455 * 7456 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7457 * 7458 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7459 */ 7460 struct sk_buff * 7461 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7462 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7463 7464 /** 7465 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7466 * collision. 7467 * 7468 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7469 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7470 * aware of. 7471 * @gfp: allocation flags 7472 */ 7473 void 7474 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7475 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7476 7477 /** 7478 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7479 * 7480 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7481 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7482 * 7483 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7484 */ 7485 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7486 { 7487 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7488 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7489 7490 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7491 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7492 } 7493 7494 /** 7495 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7496 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7497 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7498 * 7499 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls 7500 * back into the driver. 7501 * 7502 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7503 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7504 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7505 * 7506 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7507 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7508 * a sequence of calls like 7509 * 7510 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7511 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7512 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7513 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7514 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7515 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7516 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7517 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7518 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7519 */ 7520 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7521 7522 /** 7523 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7524 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7525 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7526 * 7527 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7528 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7529 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7530 * completed after it returns. 7531 */ 7532 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7533 u16 active_links); 7534 7535 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7536